annotate runtime/doc/usr_41.txt @ 13431:19f9b74a424e v8.0.1590

patch 8.0.1590: padding in list type wastes memory commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/1a840240376f2858d489736f9eed6d2975225fdf Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org> Date: Thu Mar 8 21:46:43 2018 +0100 patch 8.0.1590: padding in list type wastes memory Problem: Padding in list type wastes memory. Solution: Reorder struct members to optimize padding. (Dominique Pelle, closes #2704)
author Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
date Thu, 08 Mar 2018 22:00:05 +0100
parents acd7eaa13d2b
children 02b3f719eacb
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
13341
acd7eaa13d2b Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13280
diff changeset
1 *usr_41.txt* For Vim version 8.0. Last change: 2018 Feb 13
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3 VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5 Write a Vim script
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8 The Vim script language is used for the startup vimrc file, syntax files, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 many other things. This chapter explains the items that can be used in a Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 script. There are a lot of them, thus this is a long chapter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12 |41.1| Introduction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 |41.2| Variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14 |41.3| Expressions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 |41.4| Conditionals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 |41.5| Executing an expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 |41.6| Using functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18 |41.7| Defining a function
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
19 |41.8| Lists and Dictionaries
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
20 |41.9| Exceptions
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
21 |41.10| Various remarks
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
22 |41.11| Writing a plugin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
23 |41.12| Writing a filetype plugin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
24 |41.13| Writing a compiler plugin
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
25 |41.14| Writing a plugin that loads quickly
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
26 |41.15| Writing library scripts
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
27 |41.16| Distributing Vim scripts
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 Next chapter: |usr_42.txt| Add new menus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 Previous chapter: |usr_40.txt| Make new commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 Table of contents: |usr_toc.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33 ==============================================================================
129
2983cde45542 updated for version 7.0044
vimboss
parents: 112
diff changeset
34 *41.1* Introduction *vim-script-intro* *script*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36 Your first experience with Vim scripts is the vimrc file. Vim reads it when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 it starts up and executes the commands. You can set options to values you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
38 prefer. And you can use any colon command in it (commands that start with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
39 ":"; these are sometimes referred to as Ex commands or command-line commands).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40 Syntax files are also Vim scripts. As are files that set options for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 specific file type. A complicated macro can be defined by a separate Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42 script file. You can think of other uses yourself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 Let's start with a simple example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46 :let i = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 :while i < 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48 : echo "count is" i
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
49 : let i += 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53 The ":" characters are not really needed here. You only need to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 them when you type a command. In a Vim script file they can be left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55 out. We will use them here anyway to make clear these are colon
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56 commands and make them stand out from Normal mode commands.
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
57 Note:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
58 You can try out the examples by yanking the lines from the text here
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
59 and executing them with :@"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
60
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
61 The output of the example code is:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
62
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
63 count is 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
64 count is 2 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
65 count is 3 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
66 count is 4 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
67
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
68 In the first line the ":let" command assigns a value to a variable. The
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
69 generic form is: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 :let {variable} = {expression}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 In this case the variable name is "i" and the expression is a simple value,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 the number one.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 The ":while" command starts a loop. The generic form is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77 :while {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 : {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
80
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 The statements until the matching ":endwhile" are executed for as long as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82 condition is true. The condition used here is the expression "i < 5". This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 is true when the variable i is smaller than five.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
85 If you happen to write a while loop that keeps on running, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 interrupt it by pressing CTRL-C (CTRL-Break on MS-Windows).
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
87
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
88 The ":echo" command prints its arguments. In this case the string "count is"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
89 and the value of the variable i. Since i is one, this will print:
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
90
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
91 count is 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
92
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
93 Then there is the ":let i += 1" command. This does the same thing as
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
94 ":let i = i + 1". This adds one to the variable i and assigns the new value
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
95 to the same variable.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
96
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
97 The example was given to explain the commands, but would you really want to
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
98 make such a loop, it can be written much more compact: >
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
99
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
100 :for i in range(1, 4)
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
101 : echo "count is" i
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
102 :endfor
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
103
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
104 We won't explain how |:for| and |range()| work until later. Follow the links
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
105 if you are impatient.
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
106
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 THREE KINDS OF NUMBERS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 Numbers can be decimal, hexadecimal or octal. A hexadecimal number starts
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
111 with "0x" or "0X". For example "0x1f" is decimal 31. An octal number starts
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
112 with a zero. "017" is decimal 15. Careful: don't put a zero before a decimal
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
113 number, it will be interpreted as an octal number!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 The ":echo" command always prints decimal numbers. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
116 :echo 0x7f 036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
117 < 127 30 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
118
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
119 A number is made negative with a minus sign. This also works for hexadecimal
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
120 and octal numbers. A minus sign is also used for subtraction. Compare this
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
121 with the previous example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 :echo 0x7f -036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 < 97 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
126 White space in an expression is ignored. However, it's recommended to use it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
127 for separating items, to make the expression easier to read. For example, to
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
128 avoid the confusion with a negative number above, put a space between the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
129 minus sign and the following number: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
131 :echo 0x7f - 036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
133 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 *41.2* Variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
136 A variable name consists of ASCII letters, digits and the underscore. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
137 cannot start with a digit. Valid variable names are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
138
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139 counter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
140 _aap3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141 very_long_variable_name_with_underscores
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142 FuncLength
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 LENGTH
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 Invalid names are "foo+bar" and "6var".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 These variables are global. To see a list of currently defined variables
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147 use this command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 :let
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151 You can use global variables everywhere. This also means that when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152 variable "count" is used in one script file, it might also be used in another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 file. This leads to confusion at least, and real problems at worst. To avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154 this, you can use a variable local to a script file by prepending "s:". For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155 example, one script contains this code: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157 :let s:count = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
158 :while s:count < 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
159 : source other.vim
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
160 : let s:count += 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
161 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 Since "s:count" is local to this script, you can be sure that sourcing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164 "other.vim" script will not change this variable. If "other.vim" also uses an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
165 "s:count" variable, it will be a different copy, local to that script. More
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166 about script-local variables here: |script-variable|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168 There are more kinds of variables, see |internal-variables|. The most often
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 used ones are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 b:name variable local to a buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 w:name variable local to a window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173 g:name global variable (also in a function)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 v:name variable predefined by Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 DELETING VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179 Variables take up memory and show up in the output of the ":let" command. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 delete a variable use the ":unlet" command. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 :unlet s:count
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 This deletes the script-local variable "s:count" to free up the memory it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 uses. If you are not sure if the variable exists, and don't want an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 message when it doesn't, append !: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 :unlet! s:count
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190 When a script finishes, the local variables used there will not be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
191 automatically freed. The next time the script executes, it can still use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
192 old value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
194 :if !exists("s:call_count")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
195 : let s:call_count = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 :let s:call_count = s:call_count + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198 :echo "called" s:call_count "times"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 The "exists()" function checks if a variable has already been defined. Its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 argument is the name of the variable you want to check. Not the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
202 itself! If you would do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204 :if !exists(s:call_count)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
206 Then the value of s:call_count will be used as the name of the variable that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
207 exists() checks. That's not what you want.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
208 The exclamation mark ! negates a value. When the value was true, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
209 becomes false. When it was false, it becomes true. You can read it as "not".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
210 Thus "if !exists()" can be read as "if not exists()".
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
211 What Vim calls true is anything that is not zero. Zero is false.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
212 Note:
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
213 Vim automatically converts a string to a number when it is looking for
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
214 a number. When using a string that doesn't start with a digit the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
215 resulting number is zero. Thus look out for this: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
216 :if "true"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
217 < The "true" will be interpreted as a zero, thus as false!
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220 STRING VARIABLES AND CONSTANTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 So far only numbers were used for the variable value. Strings can be used as
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
223 well. Numbers and strings are the basic types of variables that Vim supports.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
224 The type is dynamic, it is set each time when assigning a value to the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
225 variable with ":let". More about types in |41.8|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 To assign a string value to a variable, you need to use a string constant.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 There are two types of these. First the string in double quotes: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 :let name = "peter"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231 < peter ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233 If you want to include a double quote inside the string, put a backslash in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 front of it: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 :let name = "\"peter\""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238 < "peter" ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 To avoid the need for a backslash, you can use a string in single quotes: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 :let name = '"peter"'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 :echo name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 < "peter" ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
246 Inside a single-quote string all the characters are as they are. Only the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
247 single quote itself is special: you need to use two to get one. A backslash
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
248 is taken literally, thus you can't use it to change the meaning of the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 character after it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250 In double-quote strings it is possible to use special characters. Here are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 a few useful ones:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 \t <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 \n <NL>, line break
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 \r <CR>, <Enter>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256 \e <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257 \b <BS>, backspace
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258 \" "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259 \\ \, backslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
260 \<Esc> <Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261 \<C-W> CTRL-W
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263 The last two are just examples. The "\<name>" form can be used to include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 the special key "name".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 See |expr-quote| for the full list of special items in a string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 *41.3* Expressions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 Vim has a rich, yet simple way to handle expressions. You can read the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271 definition here: |expression-syntax|. Here we will show the most common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272 items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 The numbers, strings and variables mentioned above are expressions by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 themselves. Thus everywhere an expression is expected, you can use a number,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275 string or variable. Other basic items in an expression are:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 $NAME environment variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
278 &name option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
279 @r register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
280
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
281 Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
282
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 :echo "The value of 'tabstop' is" &ts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 :echo "Your home directory is" $HOME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285 :if @a > 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 The &name form can be used to save an option value, set it to a new value,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288 do something and restore the old value. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290 :let save_ic = &ic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291 :set noic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 :/The Start/,$delete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293 :let &ic = save_ic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
295 This makes sure the "The Start" pattern is used with the 'ignorecase' option
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
296 off. Still, it keeps the value that the user had set. (Another way to do
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
297 this would be to add "\C" to the pattern, see |/\C|.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300 MATHEMATICS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302 It becomes more interesting if we combine these basic items. Let's start with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
303 mathematics on numbers:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
304
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
305 a + b add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 a - b subtract
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307 a * b multiply
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 a / b divide
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 a % b modulo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 The usual precedence is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
313 :echo 10 + 5 * 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
314 < 20 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
316 Grouping is done with parentheses. No surprises here. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 :echo (10 + 5) * 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 < 30 ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 Strings can be concatenated with ".". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 :echo "foo" . "bar"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 < foobar ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326 When the ":echo" command gets multiple arguments, it separates them with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327 space. In the example the argument is a single expression, thus no space is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 inserted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 Borrowed from the C language is the conditional expression:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332 a ? b : c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334 If "a" evaluates to true "b" is used, otherwise "c" is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 :let i = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 :echo i > 5 ? "i is big" : "i is small"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 < i is small ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 The three parts of the constructs are always evaluated first, thus you could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 see it work as:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 (a) ? (b) : (c)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 *41.4* Conditionals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 The ":if" commands executes the following statements, until the matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 ":endif", only when a condition is met. The generic form is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 Only when the expression {condition} evaluates to true (non-zero) will the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356 {statements} be executed. These must still be valid commands. If they
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 contain garbage, Vim won't be able to find the ":endif".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 You can also use ":else". The generic form for this is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 The second {statements} is only executed if the first one isn't.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 Finally, there is ":elseif":
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 :if {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 :elseif {condition}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 {statements}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375 This works just like using ":else" and then "if", but without the need for an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376 extra ":endif".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377 A useful example for your vimrc file is checking the 'term' option and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 doing something depending upon its value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 :if &term == "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 : " Do stuff for xterm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382 :elseif &term == "vt100"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
383 : " Do stuff for a vt100 terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
384 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
385 : " Do something for other terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 LOGIC OPERATIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
391 We already used some of them in the examples. These are the most often used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
392 ones:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
393
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
394 a == b equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395 a != b not equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396 a > b greater than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
397 a >= b greater than or equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398 a < b less than
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
399 a <= b less than or equal to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
400
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
401 The result is one if the condition is met and zero otherwise. An example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
403 :if v:version >= 700
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
404 : echo "congratulations"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
405 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 : echo "you are using an old version, upgrade!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
407 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
408
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
409 Here "v:version" is a variable defined by Vim, which has the value of the Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
410 version. 600 is for version 6.0. Version 6.1 has the value 601. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
411 very useful to write a script that works with multiple versions of Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
412 |v:version|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
414 The logic operators work both for numbers and strings. When comparing two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
415 strings, the mathematical difference is used. This compares byte values,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
416 which may not be right for some languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
417 When comparing a string with a number, the string is first converted to a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
418 number. This is a bit tricky, because when a string doesn't look like a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
419 number, the number zero is used. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
420
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
421 :if 0 == "one"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
422 : echo "yes"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
423 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
424
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
425 This will echo "yes", because "one" doesn't look like a number, thus it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
426 converted to the number zero.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
428 For strings there are two more items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
429
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
430 a =~ b matches with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
431 a !~ b does not match with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
432
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
433 The left item "a" is used as a string. The right item "b" is used as a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
434 pattern, like what's used for searching. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
435
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
436 :if str =~ " "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
437 : echo "str contains a space"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
438 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
439 :if str !~ '\.$'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
440 : echo "str does not end in a full stop"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
441 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
442
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
443 Notice the use of a single-quote string for the pattern. This is useful,
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
444 because backslashes would need to be doubled in a double-quote string and
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
445 patterns tend to contain many backslashes.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
446
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
447 The 'ignorecase' option is used when comparing strings. When you don't want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
448 that, append "#" to match case and "?" to ignore case. Thus "==?" compares
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
449 two strings to be equal while ignoring case. And "!~#" checks if a pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
450 doesn't match, also checking the case of letters. For the full table see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
451 |expr-==|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
453
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
454 MORE LOOPING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
455
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
456 The ":while" command was already mentioned. Two more statements can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
457 in between the ":while" and the ":endwhile":
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
458
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
459 :continue Jump back to the start of the while loop; the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
460 loop continues.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
461 :break Jump forward to the ":endwhile"; the loop is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
462 discontinued.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
464 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
465
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
466 :while counter < 40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
467 : call do_something()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
468 : if skip_flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
469 : continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
470 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
471 : if finished_flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
472 : break
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
473 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
474 : sleep 50m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
475 :endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
476
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
477 The ":sleep" command makes Vim take a nap. The "50m" specifies fifty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
478 milliseconds. Another example is ":sleep 4", which sleeps for four seconds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
479
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
480 Even more looping can be done with the ":for" command, see below in |41.8|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
481
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
482 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
483 *41.5* Executing an expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
485 So far the commands in the script were executed by Vim directly. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
486 ":execute" command allows executing the result of an expression. This is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
487 very powerful way to build commands and execute them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
488 An example is to jump to a tag, which is contained in a variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
489
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
490 :execute "tag " . tag_name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
492 The "." is used to concatenate the string "tag " with the value of variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
493 "tag_name". Suppose "tag_name" has the value "get_cmd", then the command that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
494 will be executed is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
495
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
496 :tag get_cmd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
498 The ":execute" command can only execute colon commands. The ":normal" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
499 executes Normal mode commands. However, its argument is not an expression but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
500 the literal command characters. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
502 :normal gg=G
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
503
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
504 This jumps to the first line and formats all lines with the "=" operator.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
505 To make ":normal" work with an expression, combine ":execute" with it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
506 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
507
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
508 :execute "normal " . normal_commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
509
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
510 The variable "normal_commands" must contain the Normal mode commands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
511 Make sure that the argument for ":normal" is a complete command. Otherwise
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
512 Vim will run into the end of the argument and abort the command. For example,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
513 if you start Insert mode, you must leave Insert mode as well. This works: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
514
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
515 :execute "normal Inew text \<Esc>"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
516
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
517 This inserts "new text " in the current line. Notice the use of the special
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
518 key "\<Esc>". This avoids having to enter a real <Esc> character in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
519 script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
520
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
521 If you don't want to execute a string but evaluate it to get its expression
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
522 value, you can use the eval() function: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
523
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
524 :let optname = "path"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
525 :let optval = eval('&' . optname)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
526
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
527 A "&" character is prepended to "path", thus the argument to eval() is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
528 "&path". The result will then be the value of the 'path' option.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
529 The same thing can be done with: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
530 :exe 'let optval = &' . optname
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
531
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
532 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
533 *41.6* Using functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
534
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
535 Vim defines many functions and provides a large amount of functionality that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
536 way. A few examples will be given in this section. You can find the whole
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
537 list here: |functions|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
538
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
539 A function is called with the ":call" command. The parameters are passed in
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
540 between parentheses separated by commas. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
541
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
542 :call search("Date: ", "W")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
543
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
544 This calls the search() function, with arguments "Date: " and "W". The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
545 search() function uses its first argument as a search pattern and the second
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
546 one as flags. The "W" flag means the search doesn't wrap around the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
547 the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
549 A function can be called in an expression. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
551 :let line = getline(".")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
552 :let repl = substitute(line, '\a', "*", "g")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
553 :call setline(".", repl)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
554
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
555 The getline() function obtains a line from the current buffer. Its argument
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
556 is a specification of the line number. In this case "." is used, which means
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
557 the line where the cursor is.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
558 The substitute() function does something similar to the ":substitute"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
559 command. The first argument is the string on which to perform the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
560 substitution. The second argument is the pattern, the third the replacement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
561 string. Finally, the last arguments are the flags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
562 The setline() function sets the line, specified by the first argument, to a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
563 new string, the second argument. In this example the line under the cursor is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
564 replaced with the result of the substitute(). Thus the effect of the three
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
565 statements is equal to: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
567 :substitute/\a/*/g
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
569 Using the functions becomes more interesting when you do more work before and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
570 after the substitute() call.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
571
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
573 FUNCTIONS *function-list*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
574
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
575 There are many functions. We will mention them here, grouped by what they are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
576 used for. You can find an alphabetical list here: |functions|. Use CTRL-] on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
577 the function name to jump to detailed help on it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
578
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
579 String manipulation: *string-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
580 nr2char() get a character by its ASCII value
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
581 char2nr() get ASCII value of a character
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
582 str2nr() convert a string to a Number
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
583 str2float() convert a string to a Float
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
584 printf() format a string according to % items
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
585 escape() escape characters in a string with a '\'
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
586 shellescape() escape a string for use with a shell command
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
587 fnameescape() escape a file name for use with a Vim command
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
588 tr() translate characters from one set to another
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
589 strtrans() translate a string to make it printable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
590 tolower() turn a string to lowercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
591 toupper() turn a string to uppercase
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
592 match() position where a pattern matches in a string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
593 matchend() position where a pattern match ends in a string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
594 matchstr() match of a pattern in a string
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
595 matchstrpos() match and positions of a pattern in a string
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
596 matchlist() like matchstr() and also return submatches
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
597 stridx() first index of a short string in a long string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
598 strridx() last index of a short string in a long string
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
599 strlen() length of a string in bytes
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
600 strchars() length of a string in characters
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
601 strwidth() size of string when displayed
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
602 strdisplaywidth() size of string when displayed, deals with tabs
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
603 substitute() substitute a pattern match with a string
2908
fd09a9c8468e Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2725
diff changeset
604 submatch() get a specific match in ":s" and substitute()
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
605 strpart() get part of a string using byte index
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
606 strcharpart() get part of a string using char index
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
607 strgetchar() get character from a string using char index
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
608 expand() expand special keywords
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
609 iconv() convert text from one encoding to another
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
610 byteidx() byte index of a character in a string
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
611 byteidxcomp() like byteidx() but count composing characters
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
612 repeat() repeat a string multiple times
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
613 eval() evaluate a string expression
9464
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
614 execute() execute an Ex command and get the output
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
615
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
616 List manipulation: *list-functions*
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
617 get() get an item without error for wrong index
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
618 len() number of items in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
619 empty() check if List is empty
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
620 insert() insert an item somewhere in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
621 add() append an item to a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
622 extend() append a List to a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
623 remove() remove one or more items from a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
624 copy() make a shallow copy of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
625 deepcopy() make a full copy of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
626 filter() remove selected items from a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
627 map() change each List item
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
628 sort() sort a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
629 reverse() reverse the order of a List
5763
c52a655d927d Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5618
diff changeset
630 uniq() remove copies of repeated adjacent items
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
631 split() split a String into a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
632 join() join List items into a String
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
633 range() return a List with a sequence of numbers
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
634 string() String representation of a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
635 call() call a function with List as arguments
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
636 index() index of a value in a List
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
637 max() maximum value in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
638 min() minimum value in a List
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
639 count() count number of times a value appears in a List
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
640 repeat() repeat a List multiple times
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
641
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
642 Dictionary manipulation: *dict-functions*
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
643 get() get an entry without an error for a wrong key
112
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
644 len() number of entries in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
645 has_key() check whether a key appears in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
646 empty() check if Dictionary is empty
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
647 remove() remove an entry from a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
648 extend() add entries from one Dictionary to another
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
649 filter() remove selected entries from a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
650 map() change each Dictionary entry
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
651 keys() get List of Dictionary keys
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
652 values() get List of Dictionary values
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
653 items() get List of Dictionary key-value pairs
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
654 copy() make a shallow copy of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
655 deepcopy() make a full copy of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
656 string() String representation of a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
657 max() maximum value in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
658 min() minimum value in a Dictionary
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
659 count() count number of times a value appears
195c94b60e54 updated for version 7.0041
vimboss
parents: 48
diff changeset
660
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
661 Floating point computation: *float-functions*
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
662 float2nr() convert Float to Number
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
663 abs() absolute value (also works for Number)
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
664 round() round off
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
665 ceil() round up
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
666 floor() round down
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
667 trunc() remove value after decimal point
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
668 fmod() remainder of division
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
669 exp() exponential
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
670 log() natural logarithm (logarithm to base e)
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
671 log10() logarithm to base 10
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
672 pow() value of x to the exponent y
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
673 sqrt() square root
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
674 sin() sine
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
675 cos() cosine
2725
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
676 tan() tangent
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
677 asin() arc sine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
678 acos() arc cosine
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
679 atan() arc tangent
2725
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
680 atan2() arc tangent
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
681 sinh() hyperbolic sine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
682 cosh() hyperbolic cosine
6f63330ec225 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2709
diff changeset
683 tanh() hyperbolic tangent
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
684 isnan() check for not a number
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
685
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
686 Other computation: *bitwise-function*
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
687 and() bitwise AND
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
688 invert() bitwise invert
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
689 or() bitwise OR
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
690 xor() bitwise XOR
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
691 sha256() SHA-256 hash
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2908
diff changeset
692
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
693 Variables: *var-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
694 type() type of a variable
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
695 islocked() check if a variable is locked
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
696 funcref() get a Funcref for a function reference
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
697 function() get a Funcref for a function name
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
698 getbufvar() get a variable value from a specific buffer
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
699 setbufvar() set a variable in a specific buffer
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
700 getwinvar() get a variable from specific window
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
701 gettabvar() get a variable from specific tab page
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
702 gettabwinvar() get a variable from specific window & tab page
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
703 setwinvar() set a variable in a specific window
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
704 settabvar() set a variable in a specific tab page
831
f24a95dae8ee updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
705 settabwinvar() set a variable in a specific window & tab page
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
706 garbagecollect() possibly free memory
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
707
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
708 Cursor and mark position: *cursor-functions* *mark-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
709 col() column number of the cursor or a mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
710 virtcol() screen column of the cursor or a mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
711 line() line number of the cursor or mark
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712 wincol() window column number of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
713 winline() window line number of the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714 cursor() position the cursor at a line/column
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
715 screencol() get screen column of the cursor
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
716 screenrow() get screen row of the cursor
5968
92751673cc37 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5942
diff changeset
717 getcurpos() get position of the cursor
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
718 getpos() get position of cursor, mark, etc.
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
719 setpos() set position of cursor, mark, etc.
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
720 byte2line() get line number at a specific byte count
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
721 line2byte() byte count at a specific line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
722 diff_filler() get the number of filler lines above a line
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
723 screenattr() get attribute at a screen line/row
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
724 screenchar() get character code at a screen line/row
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
725
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
726 Working with text in the current buffer: *text-functions*
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
727 getline() get a line or list of lines from the buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
728 setline() replace a line in the buffer
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
729 append() append line or list of lines in the buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730 indent() indent of a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
731 cindent() indent according to C indenting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732 lispindent() indent according to Lisp indenting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 nextnonblank() find next non-blank line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
734 prevnonblank() find previous non-blank line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 search() find a match for a pattern
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 647
diff changeset
736 searchpos() find a match for a pattern
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737 searchpair() find the other end of a start/skip/end
667
9090f866cd57 updated for version 7.0197
vimboss
parents: 647
diff changeset
738 searchpairpos() find the other end of a start/skip/end
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
739 searchdecl() search for the declaration of a name
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
740 getcharsearch() return character search information
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
741 setcharsearch() set character search information
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
743 *system-functions* *file-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 System functions and manipulation of files:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745 glob() expand wildcards
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 globpath() expand wildcards in a number of directories
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
747 glob2regpat() convert a glob pattern into a search pattern
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
748 findfile() find a file in a list of directories
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
749 finddir() find a directory in a list of directories
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750 resolve() find out where a shortcut points to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 fnamemodify() modify a file name
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
752 pathshorten() shorten directory names in a path
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
753 simplify() simplify a path without changing its meaning
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754 executable() check if an executable program exists
5814
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
755 exepath() full path of an executable program
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 filereadable() check if a file can be read
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757 filewritable() check if a file can be written to
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
758 getfperm() get the permissions of a file
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
759 setfperm() set the permissions of a file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
760 getftype() get the kind of a file
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761 isdirectory() check if a directory exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 getfsize() get the size of a file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
763 getcwd() get the current working directory
1104
d75027183cf4 updated for version 7.0-230
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
764 haslocaldir() check if current window used |:lcd|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
765 tempname() get the name of a temporary file
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
766 mkdir() create a new directory
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767 delete() delete a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 rename() rename a file
5814
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
769 system() get the result of a shell command as a string
755931e042e4 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5763
diff changeset
770 systemlist() get the result of a shell command as a list
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 hostname() name of the system
158
78423945b251 updated for version 7.0048
vimboss
parents: 129
diff changeset
772 readfile() read a file into a List of lines
78423945b251 updated for version 7.0048
vimboss
parents: 129
diff changeset
773 writefile() write a List of lines into a file
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
775 Date and Time: *date-functions* *time-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
776 getftime() get last modification time of a file
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
777 localtime() get current time in seconds
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
778 strftime() convert time to a string
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
779 reltime() get the current or elapsed time accurately
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
780 reltimestr() convert reltime() result to a string
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
781 reltimefloat() convert reltime() result to a Float
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
782
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
783 *buffer-functions* *window-functions* *arg-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
784 Buffers, windows and the argument list:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 argc() number of entries in the argument list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
786 argidx() current position in the argument list
5942
66eead134d68 updated for version 7.4.312
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5814
diff changeset
787 arglistid() get id of the argument list
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
788 argv() get one entry from the argument list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
789 bufexists() check if a buffer exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
790 buflisted() check if a buffer exists and is listed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
791 bufloaded() check if a buffer exists and is loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792 bufname() get the name of a specific buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 bufnr() get the buffer number of a specific buffer
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
794 tabpagebuflist() return List of buffers in a tab page
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
795 tabpagenr() get the number of a tab page
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
796 tabpagewinnr() like winnr() for a specified tab page
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 winnr() get the window number for the current window
9227
ecb621205ed1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/82af8710bf8d1caeeceafb1370a052cb7d92f076
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8876
diff changeset
798 bufwinid() get the window ID of a specific buffer
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 bufwinnr() get the window number of a specific buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
800 winbufnr() get the buffer number of a specific window
434
9595cf1d80a7 updated for version 7.0112
vimboss
parents: 323
diff changeset
801 getbufline() get a list of lines from the specified buffer
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
802 win_findbuf() find windows containing a buffer
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
803 win_getid() get window ID of a window
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
804 win_gotoid() go to window with ID
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
805 win_id2tabwin() get tab and window nr from window ID
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
806 win_id2win() get window nr from window ID
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
807 getbufinfo() get a list with buffer information
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
808 gettabinfo() get a list with tab page information
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
809 getwininfo() get a list with window information
13280
fbda23eb0996 patch 8.0.1514: getting the list of changes is not easy
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13246
diff changeset
810 getchangelist() get a list of change list entries
13246
dd3b2ecf91f6 patch 8.0.1497: getting the jump list requires parsing the output of :jumps
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13051
diff changeset
811 getjumplist() get a list of jump list entries
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
812
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
813 Command line: *command-line-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
814 getcmdline() get the current command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
815 getcmdpos() get position of the cursor in the command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
816 setcmdpos() set position of the cursor in the command line
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
817 getcmdtype() return the current command-line type
6153
1e8ebf870720 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5979
diff changeset
818 getcmdwintype() return the current command-line window type
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
819 getcompletion() list of command-line completion matches
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
820
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
821 Quickfix and location lists: *quickfix-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
822 getqflist() list of quickfix errors
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
823 setqflist() modify a quickfix list
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
824 getloclist() list of location list items
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
825 setloclist() modify a location list
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
826
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
827 Insert mode completion: *completion-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
828 complete() set found matches
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
829 complete_add() add to found matches
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
830 complete_check() check if completion should be aborted
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
831 pumvisible() check if the popup menu is displayed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
832
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
833 Folding: *folding-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
834 foldclosed() check for a closed fold at a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
835 foldclosedend() like foldclosed() but return the last line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
836 foldlevel() check for the fold level at a specific line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
837 foldtext() generate the line displayed for a closed fold
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
838 foldtextresult() get the text displayed for a closed fold
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
839
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
840 Syntax and highlighting: *syntax-functions* *highlighting-functions*
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
841 clearmatches() clear all matches defined by |matchadd()| and
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
842 the |:match| commands
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
843 getmatches() get all matches defined by |matchadd()| and
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
844 the |:match| commands
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
845 hlexists() check if a highlight group exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
846 hlID() get ID of a highlight group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
847 synID() get syntax ID at a specific position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
848 synIDattr() get a specific attribute of a syntax ID
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
849 synIDtrans() get translated syntax ID
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
850 synstack() get list of syntax IDs at a specific position
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
851 synconcealed() get info about concealing
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
852 diff_hlID() get highlight ID for diff mode at a position
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
853 matchadd() define a pattern to highlight (a "match")
5979
f9fa2e506b9f updated for version 7.4.330
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5968
diff changeset
854 matchaddpos() define a list of positions to highlight
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
855 matcharg() get info about |:match| arguments
1326
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
856 matchdelete() delete a match defined by |matchadd()| or a
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
857 |:match| command
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
858 setmatches() restore a list of matches saved by
22886f3d882d updated for version 7.1-040
vimboss
parents: 1252
diff changeset
859 |getmatches()|
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
860
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
861 Spelling: *spell-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
862 spellbadword() locate badly spelled word at or after cursor
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
863 spellsuggest() return suggested spelling corrections
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
864 soundfold() return the sound-a-like equivalent of a word
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
866 History: *history-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 histadd() add an item to a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 histdel() delete an item from a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 histget() get an item from a history
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870 histnr() get highest index of a history list
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
872 Interactive: *interactive-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
873 browse() put up a file requester
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
874 browsedir() put up a directory requester
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 confirm() let the user make a choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876 getchar() get a character from the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
877 getcharmod() get modifiers for the last typed character
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
878 feedkeys() put characters in the typeahead queue
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879 input() get a line from the user
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
880 inputlist() let the user pick an entry from a list
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 inputsecret() get a line from the user without showing it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 inputdialog() get a line from the user in a dialog
230
9281a51ca7a2 updated for version 7.0064
vimboss
parents: 211
diff changeset
883 inputsave() save and clear typeahead
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 inputrestore() restore typeahead
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
886 GUI: *gui-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
887 getfontname() get name of current font being used
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
888 getwinposx() X position of the GUI Vim window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
889 getwinposy() Y position of the GUI Vim window
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
890 balloon_show() set the balloon content
12909
1578c0ba0dd1 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12756
diff changeset
891 balloon_split() split a message for a balloon
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
892
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
893 Vim server: *server-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 serverlist() return the list of server names
12756
3b26420fc639 Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12254
diff changeset
895 remote_startserver() run a server
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
896 remote_send() send command characters to a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
897 remote_expr() evaluate an expression in a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 server2client() send a reply to a client of a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 remote_peek() check if there is a reply from a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 remote_read() read a reply from a Vim server
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
901 foreground() move the Vim window to the foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902 remote_foreground() move the Vim server window to the foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
903
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
904 Window size and position: *window-size-functions*
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
905 winheight() get height of a specific window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
906 winwidth() get width of a specific window
13051
a6d3e2081544 Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 12909
diff changeset
907 win_screenpos() get screen position of a window
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
908 winrestcmd() return command to restore window sizes
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
909 winsaveview() get view of current window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
910 winrestview() restore saved view of current window
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
911
4159
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
912 Mappings: *mapping-functions*
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
913 hasmapto() check if a mapping exists
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
914 mapcheck() check if a matching mapping exists
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
915 maparg() get rhs of a mapping
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
916 wildmenumode() check if the wildmode is active
8b86b69546a9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3893
diff changeset
917
7279
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
918 Testing: *test-functions*
8673
ed7251c3e2d3 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18c0b39815c5a746887a509c2cd9f11fadaba07
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8061
diff changeset
919 assert_equal() assert that two expressions values are equal
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
920 assert_notequal() assert that two expressions values are not equal
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
921 assert_inrange() assert that an expression is inside a range
8795
aba2d0a01290 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7db8f6f4f85e5d0526d23107b2a5e2334dc23354
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8793
diff changeset
922 assert_match() assert that a pattern matches the value
8876
47f17f66da3d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8795
diff changeset
923 assert_notmatch() assert that a pattern does not match the value
7279
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
924 assert_false() assert that an expression is false
b5e9810b389d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 6153
diff changeset
925 assert_true() assert that an expression is true
8673
ed7251c3e2d3 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18c0b39815c5a746887a509c2cd9f11fadaba07
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 8061
diff changeset
926 assert_exception() assert that a command throws an exception
13341
acd7eaa13d2b Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13280
diff changeset
927 assert_beeps() assert that a command beeps
acd7eaa13d2b Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 13280
diff changeset
928 assert_fails() assert that a command fails
11229
146a1e213b60 Update runtime files. Add Rust support.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11160
diff changeset
929 assert_report() report a test failure
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
930 test_alloc_fail() make memory allocation fail
9644
9f7bcc2c3b97 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/6f1d9a096bf22d50c727dca73abbfb8e3ff55176
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9464
diff changeset
931 test_autochdir() enable 'autochdir' during startup
11160
d0a20101ecb2 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11062
diff changeset
932 test_override() test with Vim internal overrides
d0a20101ecb2 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11062
diff changeset
933 test_garbagecollect_now() free memory right now
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
934 test_ignore_error() ignore a specific error message
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
935 test_null_channel() return a null Channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
936 test_null_dict() return a null Dict
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
937 test_null_job() return a null Job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
938 test_null_list() return a null List
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
939 test_null_partial() return a null Partial function
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
940 test_null_string() return a null String
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
941 test_settime() set the time Vim uses internally
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
942
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
943 Inter-process communication: *channel-functions*
10449
222b1432814e commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10198
diff changeset
944 ch_canread() check if there is something to read
7924
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
945 ch_open() open a channel
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
946 ch_close() close a channel
10140
b11ceef7116e commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9858
diff changeset
947 ch_close_in() close the in part of a channel
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
948 ch_read() read a message from a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
949 ch_readraw() read a raw message from a channel
7924
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
950 ch_sendexpr() send a JSON message over a channel
00d64eb49ce1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/681baaf4a4c81418693dcafb81421a8614832e91
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7790
diff changeset
951 ch_sendraw() send a raw message over a channel
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
952 ch_evalexpr() evaluates an expression over channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
953 ch_evalraw() evaluates a raw string over channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
954 ch_status() get status of a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
955 ch_getbufnr() get the buffer number of a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
956 ch_getjob() get the job associated with a channel
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
957 ch_info() get channel information
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
958 ch_log() write a message in the channel log file
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
959 ch_logfile() set the channel log file
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
960 ch_setoptions() set the options for a channel
9319
1472ed67c36f commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a02a551e18209423584fcb923e93c6be18f3aa45
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9286
diff changeset
961 json_encode() encode an expression to a JSON string
1472ed67c36f commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a02a551e18209423584fcb923e93c6be18f3aa45
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9286
diff changeset
962 json_decode() decode a JSON string to Vim types
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
963 js_encode() encode an expression to a JSON string
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
964 js_decode() decode a JSON string to Vim types
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
965
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
966 Jobs: *job-functions*
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
967 job_start() start a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
968 job_stop() stop a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
969 job_status() get the status of a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
970 job_getchannel() get the channel used by a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
971 job_info() get information about a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
972 job_setoptions() set options for a job
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
973
12254
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
974 Terminal window: *terminal-functions*
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
975 term_start() open a terminal window and run a job
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
976 term_list() get the list of terminal buffers
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
977 term_sendkeys() send keystrokes to a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
978 term_wait() wait for screen to be updated
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
979 term_getjob() get the job associated with a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
980 term_scrape() get row of a terminal screen
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
981 term_getline() get a line of text from a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
982 term_getattr() get the value of attribute {what}
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
983 term_getcursor() get the cursor position of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
984 term_getscrolled() get the scroll count of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
985 term_getaltscreen() get the alternate screen flag
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
986 term_getsize() get the size of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
987 term_getstatus() get the status of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
988 term_gettitle() get the title of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
989 term_gettty() get the tty name of a terminal
8d76a56861ec Update runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11763
diff changeset
990
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
991 Timers: *timer-functions*
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
992 timer_start() create a timer
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
993 timer_pause() pause or unpause a timer
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
994 timer_stop() stop a timer
9858
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
995 timer_stopall() stop all timers
3e96d9ed2ca1 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b5ae48e9ffd3b8eb6ca4057de11f1bddcde8ce6f
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9644
diff changeset
996 timer_info() get information about timers
7790
ca19726d5e83 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/298b440930ecece38d6ea0505a3e582dc817e79b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7651
diff changeset
997
2301
6f63294a1781 Avoid use of the GTK mail_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
998 Various: *various-functions*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999 mode() get current editing mode
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1000 visualmode() last visual mode used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1001 exists() check if a variable, function, etc. exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1002 has() check if a feature is supported in Vim
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1003 changenr() return number of most recent change
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1004 cscope_connection() check if a cscope connection exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1005 did_filetype() check if a FileType autocommand was used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1006 eventhandler() check if invoked by an event handler
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1007 getpid() get process ID of Vim
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1008
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1009 libcall() call a function in an external library
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1010 libcallnr() idem, returning a number
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1011
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1012 undofile() get the name of the undo file
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1013 undotree() return the state of the undo tree
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1014
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1015 getreg() get contents of a register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1016 getregtype() get type of a register
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1017 setreg() set contents and type of a register
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1018
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1019 shiftwidth() effective value of 'shiftwidth'
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1020
9464
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
1021 wordcount() get byte/word/char count of buffer
be72f4201a1d commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9319
diff changeset
1022
211
79c3648993c3 updated for version 7.0060
vimboss
parents: 170
diff changeset
1023 taglist() get list of matching tags
824
8dd456c1e283 updated for version 7.0c13
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
1024 tagfiles() get a list of tags files
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1025
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1026 luaeval() evaluate Lua expression
2050
afcf9db31561 updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
1027 mzeval() evaluate |MzScheme| expression
7651
c7575b07de98 commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7480
diff changeset
1028 perleval() evaluate Perl expression (|+perl|)
5618
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1029 py3eval() evaluate Python expression (|+python3|)
350272cbf1fd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 5294
diff changeset
1030 pyeval() evaluate Python expression (|+python|)
10734
523cd59d6db0 Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10449
diff changeset
1031 pyxeval() evaluate |python_x| expression
2050
afcf9db31561 updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
1032
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1033 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1034 *41.7* Defining a function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1035
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1036 Vim enables you to define your own functions. The basic function declaration
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1037 begins as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1039 :function {name}({var1}, {var2}, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1040 : {body}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1044 Function names must begin with a capital letter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1045
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046 Let's define a short function to return the smaller of two numbers. It starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1047 with this line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1049 :function Min(num1, num2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1050
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1051 This tells Vim that the function is named "Min" and it takes two arguments:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1052 "num1" and "num2".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1053 The first thing you need to do is to check to see which number is smaller:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1054 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1055 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1056
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1057 The special prefix "a:" tells Vim that the variable is a function argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1058 Let's assign the variable "smaller" the value of the smallest number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1059
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1060 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1061 : let smaller = a:num1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1062 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1063 : let smaller = a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1064 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1065
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 The variable "smaller" is a local variable. Variables used inside a function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067 are local unless prefixed by something like "g:", "a:", or "s:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 Note:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070 To access a global variable from inside a function you must prepend
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1071 "g:" to it. Thus "g:today" inside a function is used for the global
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1072 variable "today", and "today" is another variable, local to the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073 function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1075 You now use the ":return" statement to return the smallest number to the user.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1076 Finally, you end the function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078 : return smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1081 The complete function definition is as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083 :function Min(num1, num2)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1084 : if a:num1 < a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1085 : let smaller = a:num1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1086 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1087 : let smaller = a:num2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1088 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1089 : return smaller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1090 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1091
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1092 For people who like short functions, this does the same thing: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1093
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1094 :function Min(num1, num2)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1095 : if a:num1 < a:num2
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1096 : return a:num1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1097 : endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1098 : return a:num2
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1099 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1100
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
1101 A user defined function is called in exactly the same way as a built-in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1102 function. Only the name is different. The Min function can be used like
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1103 this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1104
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1105 :echo Min(5, 8)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1106
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1107 Only now will the function be executed and the lines be interpreted by Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1108 If there are mistakes, like using an undefined variable or function, you will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1109 now get an error message. When defining the function these errors are not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1110 detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1111
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1112 When a function reaches ":endfunction" or ":return" is used without an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1113 argument, the function returns zero.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1114
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1115 To redefine a function that already exists, use the ! for the ":function"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1116 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1117
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1118 :function! Min(num1, num2, num3)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1119
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1120
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1121 USING A RANGE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1123 The ":call" command can be given a line range. This can have one of two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1124 meanings. When a function has been defined with the "range" keyword, it will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1125 take care of the line range itself.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1126 The function will be passed the variables "a:firstline" and "a:lastline".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1127 These will have the line numbers from the range the function was called with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1128 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1129
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1130 :function Count_words() range
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1131 : let lnum = a:firstline
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1132 : let n = 0
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1133 : while lnum <= a:lastline
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1134 : let n = n + len(split(getline(lnum)))
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1135 : let lnum = lnum + 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1136 : endwhile
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1137 : echo "found " . n . " words"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1138 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1139
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1140 You can call this function with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1142 :10,30call Count_words()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1144 It will be executed once and echo the number of words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1145 The other way to use a line range is by defining a function without the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1146 "range" keyword. The function will be called once for every line in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1147 range, with the cursor in that line. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1148
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1149 :function Number()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1150 : echo "line " . line(".") . " contains: " . getline(".")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1151 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1152
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1153 If you call this function with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1155 :10,15call Number()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1156
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1157 The function will be called six times.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1159
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1160 VARIABLE NUMBER OF ARGUMENTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1161
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1162 Vim enables you to define functions that have a variable number of arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1163 The following command, for instance, defines a function that must have 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164 argument (start) and can have up to 20 additional arguments: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1165
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166 :function Show(start, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168 The variable "a:1" contains the first optional argument, "a:2" the second, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1169 so on. The variable "a:0" contains the number of extra arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1172 :function Show(start, ...)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 : echohl Title
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1174 : echo "start is " . a:start
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 : echohl None
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176 : let index = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 : while index <= a:0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 : echo " Arg " . index . " is " . a:{index}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 : let index = index + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 : endwhile
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 : echo ""
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1182 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 This uses the ":echohl" command to specify the highlighting used for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185 following ":echo" command. ":echohl None" stops it again. The ":echon"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 command works like ":echo", but doesn't output a line break.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1188 You can also use the a:000 variable, it is a List of all the "..." arguments.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1189 See |a:000|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1190
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1191
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1192 LISTING FUNCTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1194 The ":function" command lists the names and arguments of all user-defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1195 functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1196
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1197 :function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1198 < function Show(start, ...) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1199 function GetVimIndent() ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1200 function SetSyn(name) ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1201
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 To see what a function does, use its name as an argument for ":function": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1204 :function SetSyn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1205 < 1 if &syntax == '' ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1206 2 let &syntax = a:name ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1207 3 endif ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1208 endfunction ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1209
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211 DEBUGGING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 The line number is useful for when you get an error message or when debugging.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214 See |debug-scripts| about debugging mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215 You can also set the 'verbose' option to 12 or higher to see all function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 calls. Set it to 15 or higher to see every executed line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219 DELETING A FUNCTION
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221 To delete the Show() function: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 :delfunction Show
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1225 You get an error when the function doesn't exist.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1226
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1227
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1228 FUNCTION REFERENCES
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1229
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1230 Sometimes it can be useful to have a variable point to one function or
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1231 another. You can do it with the function() function. It turns the name of a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1232 function into a reference: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1233
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1234 :let result = 0 " or 1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1235 :function! Right()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1236 : return 'Right!'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1237 :endfunc
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1238 :function! Wrong()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1239 : return 'Wrong!'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1240 :endfunc
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1241 :
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1242 :if result == 1
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1243 : let Afunc = function('Right')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1244 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1245 : let Afunc = function('Wrong')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1246 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1247 :echo call(Afunc, [])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1248 < Wrong! ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1249
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1250 Note that the name of a variable that holds a function reference must start
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1251 with a capital. Otherwise it could be confused with the name of a builtin
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1252 function.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1253 The way to invoke a function that a variable refers to is with the call()
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1254 function. Its first argument is the function reference, the second argument
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1255 is a List with arguments.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1256
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1257 Function references are most useful in combination with a Dictionary, as is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1258 explained in the next section.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1259
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1260 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1261 *41.8* Lists and Dictionaries
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1262
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1263 So far we have used the basic types String and Number. Vim also supports two
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1264 composite types: List and Dictionary.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1265
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1266 A List is an ordered sequence of things. The things can be any kind of value,
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1267 thus you can make a List of numbers, a List of Lists and even a List of mixed
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1268 items. To create a List with three strings: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1269
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1270 :let alist = ['aap', 'mies', 'noot']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1271
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1272 The List items are enclosed in square brackets and separated by commas. To
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1273 create an empty List: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1274
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1275 :let alist = []
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1276
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1277 You can add items to a List with the add() function: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1278
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1279 :let alist = []
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1280 :call add(alist, 'foo')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1281 :call add(alist, 'bar')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1282 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1283 < ['foo', 'bar'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1284
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1285 List concatenation is done with +: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1286
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1287 :echo alist + ['foo', 'bar']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1288 < ['foo', 'bar', 'foo', 'bar'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1289
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1290 Or, if you want to extend a List directly: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1291
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1292 :let alist = ['one']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1293 :call extend(alist, ['two', 'three'])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1294 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1295 < ['one', 'two', 'three'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1296
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1297 Notice that using add() will have a different effect: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1298
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1299 :let alist = ['one']
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1300 :call add(alist, ['two', 'three'])
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1301 :echo alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1302 < ['one', ['two', 'three']] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1303
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1304 The second argument of add() is added as a single item.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1305
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1306
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1307 FOR LOOP
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1308
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1309 One of the nice things you can do with a List is iterate over it: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1310
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1311 :let alist = ['one', 'two', 'three']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1312 :for n in alist
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1313 : echo n
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1314 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1315 < one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1316 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1317 three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1318
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1319 This will loop over each element in List "alist", assigning the value to
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1320 variable "n". The generic form of a for loop is: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1321
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1322 :for {varname} in {listexpression}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1323 : {commands}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1324 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1325
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1326 To loop a certain number of times you need a List of a specific length. The
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1327 range() function creates one for you: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1328
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1329 :for a in range(3)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1330 : echo a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1331 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1332 < 0 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1333 1 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1334 2 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1335
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1336 Notice that the first item of the List that range() produces is zero, thus the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1337 last item is one less than the length of the list.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1338 You can also specify the maximum value, the stride and even go backwards: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1339
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1340 :for a in range(8, 4, -2)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1341 : echo a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1342 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1343 < 8 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1344 6 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1345 4 ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1346
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1347 A more useful example, looping over lines in the buffer: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1348
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1349 :for line in getline(1, 20)
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1350 : if line =~ "Date: "
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1351 : echo matchstr(line, 'Date: \zs.*')
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1352 : endif
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1353 :endfor
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1354
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1355 This looks into lines 1 to 20 (inclusive) and echoes any date found in there.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1356
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1357
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1358 DICTIONARIES
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1359
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1360 A Dictionary stores key-value pairs. You can quickly lookup a value if you
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1361 know the key. A Dictionary is created with curly braces: >
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
1362
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1363 :let uk2nl = {'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee', 'three': 'drie'}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1364
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1365 Now you can lookup words by putting the key in square brackets: >
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1366
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1367 :echo uk2nl['two']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1368 < twee ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1369
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1370 The generic form for defining a Dictionary is: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1371
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1372 {<key> : <value>, ...}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1373
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1374 An empty Dictionary is one without any keys: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1375
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1376 {}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1377
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1378 The possibilities with Dictionaries are numerous. There are various functions
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1379 for them as well. For example, you can obtain a list of the keys and loop
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1380 over them: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1381
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1382 :for key in keys(uk2nl)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1383 : echo key
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1384 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1385 < three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1386 one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1387 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1388
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
1389 You will notice the keys are not ordered. You can sort the list to get a
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1390 specific order: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1391
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1392 :for key in sort(keys(uk2nl))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1393 : echo key
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1394 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1395 < one ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1396 three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1397 two ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1398
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1399 But you can never get back the order in which items are defined. For that you
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1400 need to use a List, it stores items in an ordered sequence.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1401
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1402
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1403 DICTIONARY FUNCTIONS
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1404
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1405 The items in a Dictionary can normally be obtained with an index in square
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1406 brackets: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1407
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1408 :echo uk2nl['one']
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1409 < een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1410
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1411 A method that does the same, but without so many punctuation characters: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1412
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1413 :echo uk2nl.one
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1414 < een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1415
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1416 This only works for a key that is made of ASCII letters, digits and the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1417 underscore. You can also assign a new value this way: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1418
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1419 :let uk2nl.four = 'vier'
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1420 :echo uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1421 < {'three': 'drie', 'four': 'vier', 'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee'} ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1422
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1423 And now for something special: you can directly define a function and store a
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1424 reference to it in the dictionary: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1425
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1426 :function uk2nl.translate(line) dict
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1427 : return join(map(split(a:line), 'get(self, v:val, "???")'))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1428 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1429
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1430 Let's first try it out: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1431
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1432 :echo uk2nl.translate('three two five one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1433 < drie twee ??? een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1434
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1435 The first special thing you notice is the "dict" at the end of the ":function"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1436 line. This marks the function as being used from a Dictionary. The "self"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1437 local variable will then refer to that Dictionary.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1438 Now let's break up the complicated return command: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1439
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1440 split(a:line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1441
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1442 The split() function takes a string, chops it into whitespace separated words
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1443 and returns a list with these words. Thus in the example it returns: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1444
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1445 :echo split('three two five one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1446 < ['three', 'two', 'five', 'one'] ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1447
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1448 This list is the first argument to the map() function. This will go through
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1449 the list, evaluating its second argument with "v:val" set to the value of each
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1450 item. This is a shortcut to using a for loop. This command: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1451
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1452 :let alist = map(split(a:line), 'get(self, v:val, "???")')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1453
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1454 Is equivalent to: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1455
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1456 :let alist = split(a:line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1457 :for idx in range(len(alist))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1458 : let alist[idx] = get(self, alist[idx], "???")
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1459 :endfor
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1460
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1461 The get() function checks if a key is present in a Dictionary. If it is, then
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1462 the value is retrieved. If it isn't, then the default value is returned, in
164
8b0ee9d57d7f updated for version 7.0050
vimboss
parents: 161
diff changeset
1463 the example it's '???'. This is a convenient way to handle situations where a
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1464 key may not be present and you don't want an error message.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1465
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1466 The join() function does the opposite of split(): it joins together a list of
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1467 words, putting a space in between.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1468 This combination of split(), map() and join() is a nice way to filter a line
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1469 of words in a very compact way.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1470
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1471
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1472 OBJECT ORIENTED PROGRAMMING
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1473
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1474 Now that you can put both values and functions in a Dictionary, you can
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1475 actually use a Dictionary like an object.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1476 Above we used a Dictionary for translating Dutch to English. We might want
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1477 to do the same for other languages. Let's first make an object (aka
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1478 Dictionary) that has the translate function, but no words to translate: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1479
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1480 :let transdict = {}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1481 :function transdict.translate(line) dict
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1482 : return join(map(split(a:line), 'get(self.words, v:val, "???")'))
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1483 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1484
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1485 It's slightly different from the function above, using 'self.words' to lookup
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1486 word translations. But we don't have a self.words. Thus you could call this
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1487 an abstract class.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1488
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1489 Now we can instantiate a Dutch translation object: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1490
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1491 :let uk2nl = copy(transdict)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1492 :let uk2nl.words = {'one': 'een', 'two': 'twee', 'three': 'drie'}
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1493 :echo uk2nl.translate('three one')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1494 < drie een ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1495
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1496 And a German translator: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1497
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1498 :let uk2de = copy(transdict)
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1499 :let uk2de.words = {'one': 'eins', 'two': 'zwei', 'three': 'drei'}
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1500 :echo uk2de.translate('three one')
9286
64035abb986b commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 9227
diff changeset
1501 < drei eins ~
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1502
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1503 You see that the copy() function is used to make a copy of the "transdict"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1504 Dictionary and then the copy is changed to add the words. The original
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1505 remains the same, of course.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1506
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1507 Now you can go one step further, and use your preferred translator: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1508
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1509 :if $LANG =~ "de"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1510 : let trans = uk2de
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1511 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1512 : let trans = uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1513 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1514 :echo trans.translate('one two three')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1515 < een twee drie ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1516
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1517 Here "trans" refers to one of the two objects (Dictionaries). No copy is
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1518 made. More about List and Dictionary identity can be found at |list-identity|
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1519 and |dict-identity|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1520
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1521 Now you might use a language that isn't supported. You can overrule the
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1522 translate() function to do nothing: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1523
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1524 :let uk2uk = copy(transdict)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1525 :function! uk2uk.translate(line)
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1526 : return a:line
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1527 :endfunction
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1528 :echo uk2uk.translate('three one wladiwostok')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1529 < three one wladiwostok ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1530
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1531 Notice that a ! was used to overwrite the existing function reference. Now
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1532 use "uk2uk" when no recognized language is found: >
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1533
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1534 :if $LANG =~ "de"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1535 : let trans = uk2de
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1536 :elseif $LANG =~ "nl"
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1537 : let trans = uk2nl
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1538 :else
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1539 : let trans = uk2uk
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1540 :endif
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1541 :echo trans.translate('one two three')
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1542 < one two three ~
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1543
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1544 For further reading see |Lists| and |Dictionaries|.
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1545
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1546 ==============================================================================
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1547 *41.9* Exceptions
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1549 Let's start with an example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1551 :try
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1552 : read ~/templates/pascal.tmpl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1553 :catch /E484:/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 : echo "Sorry, the Pascal template file cannot be found."
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 The ":read" command will fail if the file does not exist. Instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 generating an error message, this code catches the error and gives the user a
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1559 nice message.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1560
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 For the commands in between ":try" and ":endtry" errors are turned into
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562 exceptions. An exception is a string. In the case of an error the string
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1563 contains the error message. And every error message has a number. In this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 case, the error we catch contains "E484:". This number is guaranteed to stay
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 the same (the text may change, e.g., it may be translated).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1567 When the ":read" command causes another error, the pattern "E484:" will not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1568 match in it. Thus this exception will not be caught and result in the usual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569 error message.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571 You might be tempted to do this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 :try
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 : read ~/templates/pascal.tmpl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 :catch
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 : echo "Sorry, the Pascal template file cannot be found."
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1579 This means all errors are caught. But then you will not see errors that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580 useful, such as "E21: Cannot make changes, 'modifiable' is off".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582 Another useful mechanism is the ":finally" command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 :let tmp = tempname()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 :try
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 : exe ".,$write " . tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587 : exe "!filter " . tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588 : .,$delete
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1589 : exe "$read " . tmp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1590 :finally
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1591 : call delete(tmp)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1592 :endtry
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1593
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1594 This filters the lines from the cursor until the end of the file through the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1595 "filter" command, which takes a file name argument. No matter if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1596 filtering works, something goes wrong in between ":try" and ":finally" or the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1597 user cancels the filtering by pressing CTRL-C, the "call delete(tmp)" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1598 always executed. This makes sure you don't leave the temporary file behind.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1600 More information about exception handling can be found in the reference
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1601 manual: |exception-handling|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1602
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1603 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1604 *41.10* Various remarks
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1605
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1606 Here is a summary of items that apply to Vim scripts. They are also mentioned
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1607 elsewhere, but form a nice checklist.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1608
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1609 The end-of-line character depends on the system. For Unix a single <NL>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1610 character is used. For MS-DOS, Windows, OS/2 and the like, <CR><LF> is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1611 This is important when using mappings that end in a <CR>. See |:source_crnl|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1613
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1614 WHITE SPACE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1615
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1616 Blank lines are allowed and ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618 Leading whitespace characters (blanks and TABs) are always ignored. The
11062
1218c5353e2b Runtime file updates.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 10734
diff changeset
1619 whitespaces between parameters (e.g. between the "set" and the "cpoptions" in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1620 the example below) are reduced to one blank character and plays the role of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1621 separator, the whitespaces after the last (visible) character may or may not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1622 be ignored depending on the situation, see below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1623
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1624 For a ":set" command involving the "=" (equal) sign, such as in: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1625
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1626 :set cpoptions =aABceFst
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1627
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1628 the whitespace immediately before the "=" sign is ignored. But there can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1629 no whitespace after the "=" sign!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1630
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1631 To include a whitespace character in the value of an option, it must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1632 escaped by a "\" (backslash) as in the following example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1633
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1634 :set tags=my\ nice\ file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1635
2709
b01a37ab556b Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
1636 The same example written as: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1637
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1638 :set tags=my nice file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1639
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1640 will issue an error, because it is interpreted as: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1641
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1642 :set tags=my
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1643 :set nice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1644 :set file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1646
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1647 COMMENTS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1648
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1649 The character " (the double quote mark) starts a comment. Everything after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1650 and including this character until the end-of-line is considered a comment and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1651 is ignored, except for commands that don't consider comments, as shown in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1652 examples below. A comment can start on any character position on the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1653
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1654 There is a little "catch" with comments for some commands. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1655
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1656 :abbrev dev development " shorthand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1657 :map <F3> o#include " insert include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1658 :execute cmd " do it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1659 :!ls *.c " list C files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 The abbreviation 'dev' will be expanded to 'development " shorthand'. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662 mapping of <F3> will actually be the whole line after the 'o# ....' including
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 the '" insert include'. The "execute" command will give an error. The "!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1664 command will send everything after it to the shell, causing an error for an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1665 unmatched '"' character.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1666 There can be no comment after ":map", ":abbreviate", ":execute" and "!"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1667 commands (there are a few more commands with this restriction). For the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1668 ":map", ":abbreviate" and ":execute" commands there is a trick: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1669
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1670 :abbrev dev development|" shorthand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1671 :map <F3> o#include|" insert include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1672 :execute cmd |" do it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1673
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1674 With the '|' character the command is separated from the next one. And that
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1675 next command is only a comment. For the last command you need to do two
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1676 things: |:execute| and use '|': >
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1677 :exe '!ls *.c' |" list C files
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1679 Notice that there is no white space before the '|' in the abbreviation and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1680 mapping. For these commands, any character until the end-of-line or '|' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1681 included. As a consequence of this behavior, you don't always see that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1682 trailing whitespace is included: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1683
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1684 :map <F4> o#include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1685
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1686 To spot these problems, you can set the 'list' option when editing vimrc
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1687 files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1688
1146
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1689 For Unix there is one special way to comment a line, that allows making a Vim
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1690 script executable: >
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1691 #!/usr/bin/env vim -S
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1692 echo "this is a Vim script"
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1693 quit
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1694
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1695 The "#" command by itself lists a line with the line number. Adding an
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1696 exclamation mark changes it into doing nothing, so that you can add the shell
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1697 command to execute the rest of the file. |:#!| |-S|
0e8da252bda1 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 1104
diff changeset
1698
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1699
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1700 PITFALLS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1702 Even bigger problem arises in the following example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 :map ,ab o#include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705 :unmap ,ab
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 Here the unmap command will not work, because it tries to unmap ",ab ". This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1708 does not exist as a mapped sequence. An error will be issued, which is very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 hard to identify, because the ending whitespace character in ":unmap ,ab " is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 not visible.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 And this is the same as what happens when one uses a comment after an 'unmap'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715 :unmap ,ab " comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1716
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717 Here the comment part will be ignored. However, Vim will try to unmap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 ',ab ', which does not exist. Rewrite it as: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 :unmap ,ab| " comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723 RESTORING THE VIEW
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1724
3893
c3036f1dca68 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3830
diff changeset
1725 Sometimes you want to make a change and go back to where the cursor was.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726 Restoring the relative position would also be nice, so that the same line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727 appears at the top of the window.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 This example yanks the current line, puts it above the first line in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 file and then restores the view: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1731 map ,p ma"aYHmbgg"aP`bzt`a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1733 What this does: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734 ma"aYHmbgg"aP`bzt`a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735 < ma set mark a at cursor position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736 "aY yank current line into register a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737 Hmb go to top line in window and set mark b there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1738 gg go to first line in file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1739 "aP put the yanked line above it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1740 `b go back to top line in display
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 zt position the text in the window as before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 `a go back to saved cursor position
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1744
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745 PACKAGING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 To avoid your function names to interfere with functions that you get from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1748 others, use this scheme:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 - Prepend a unique string before each function name. I often use an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750 abbreviation. For example, "OW_" is used for the option window functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1751 - Put the definition of your functions together in a file. Set a global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1752 variable to indicate that the functions have been loaded. When sourcing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1753 file again, first unload the functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1754 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756 " This is the XXX package
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758 if exists("XXX_loaded")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 delfun XXX_one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1760 delfun XXX_two
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 function XXX_one(a)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764 ... body of function ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1765 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1766
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1767 function XXX_two(b)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1768 ... body of function ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1769 endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 let XXX_loaded = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
1774 *41.11* Writing a plugin *write-plugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 You can write a Vim script in such a way that many people can use it. This is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777 called a plugin. Vim users can drop your script in their plugin directory and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 use its features right away |add-plugin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 There are actually two types of plugins:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1782 global plugins: For all types of files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783 filetype plugins: Only for files of a specific type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1785 In this section the first type is explained. Most items are also relevant for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1786 writing filetype plugins. The specifics for filetype plugins are in the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1787 section |write-filetype-plugin|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1789
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1790 NAME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1792 First of all you must choose a name for your plugin. The features provided
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1793 by the plugin should be clear from its name. And it should be unlikely that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1794 someone else writes a plugin with the same name but which does something
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795 different. And please limit the name to 8 characters, to avoid problems on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1796 old Windows systems.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1797
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798 A script that corrects typing mistakes could be called "typecorr.vim". We
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799 will use it here as an example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1800
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801 For the plugin to work for everybody, it should follow a few guidelines. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802 will be explained step-by-step. The complete example plugin is at the end.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1803
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1804
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1805 BODY
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1807 Let's start with the body of the plugin, the lines that do the actual work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1808
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1809 14 iabbrev teh the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1810 15 iabbrev otehr other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1811 16 iabbrev wnat want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1812 17 iabbrev synchronisation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1813 18 \ synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1814 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1815
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1816 The actual list should be much longer, of course.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1817
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1818 The line numbers have only been added to explain a few things, don't put them
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1819 in your plugin file!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1820
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1821
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1822 HEADER
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1823
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1824 You will probably add new corrections to the plugin and soon have several
3830
04592728474a Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
1825 versions lying around. And when distributing this file, people will want to
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1826 know who wrote this wonderful plugin and where they can send remarks.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1827 Therefore, put a header at the top of your plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1828
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1829 1 " Vim global plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1830 2 " Last Change: 2000 Oct 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1831 3 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1832
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833 About copyright and licensing: Since plugins are very useful and it's hardly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834 worth restricting their distribution, please consider making your plugin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835 either public domain or use the Vim |license|. A short note about this near
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1836 the top of the plugin should be sufficient. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 4 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841 LINE CONTINUATION, AVOIDING SIDE EFFECTS *use-cpo-save*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 In line 18 above, the line-continuation mechanism is used |line-continuation|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844 Users with 'compatible' set will run into trouble here, they will get an error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845 message. We can't just reset 'compatible', because that has a lot of side
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1846 effects. To avoid this, we will set the 'cpoptions' option to its Vim default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847 value and restore it later. That will allow the use of line-continuation and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1848 make the script work for most people. It is done like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 11 let s:save_cpo = &cpo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851 12 set cpo&vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1852 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1853 42 let &cpo = s:save_cpo
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
1854 43 unlet s:save_cpo
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 We first store the old value of 'cpoptions' in the s:save_cpo variable. At
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857 the end of the plugin this value is restored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859 Notice that a script-local variable is used |s:var|. A global variable could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 already be in use for something else. Always use script-local variables for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861 things that are only used in the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1863
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864 NOT LOADING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 It's possible that a user doesn't always want to load this plugin. Or the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1867 system administrator has dropped it in the system-wide plugin directory, but a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868 user has his own plugin he wants to use. Then the user must have a chance to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869 disable loading this specific plugin. This will make it possible: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1871 6 if exists("g:loaded_typecorr")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 7 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873 8 endif
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1874 9 let g:loaded_typecorr = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876 This also avoids that when the script is loaded twice it would cause error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877 messages for redefining functions and cause trouble for autocommands that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878 added twice.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1880 The name is recommended to start with "loaded_" and then the file name of the
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1881 plugin, literally. The "g:" is prepended just to avoid mistakes when using
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1882 the variable in a function (without "g:" it would be a variable local to the
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1883 function).
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1884
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1885 Using "finish" stops Vim from reading the rest of the file, it's much quicker
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1886 than using if-endif around the whole file.
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
1887
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1889 MAPPING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1890
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1891 Now let's make the plugin more interesting: We will add a mapping that adds a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1892 correction for the word under the cursor. We could just pick a key sequence
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1893 for this mapping, but the user might already use it for something else. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1894 allow the user to define which keys a mapping in a plugin uses, the <Leader>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1895 item can be used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1898
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899 The "<Plug>TypecorrAdd" thing will do the work, more about that further on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1901 The user can set the "mapleader" variable to the key sequence that he wants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 this mapping to start with. Thus if the user has done: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904 let mapleader = "_"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1906 the mapping will define "_a". If the user didn't do this, the default value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907 will be used, which is a backslash. Then a map for "\a" will be defined.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 Note that <unique> is used, this will cause an error message if the mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1910 already happened to exist. |:map-<unique>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912 But what if the user wants to define his own key sequence? We can allow that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 with this mechanism: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915 21 if !hasmapto('<Plug>TypecorrAdd')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1916 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917 23 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 This checks if a mapping to "<Plug>TypecorrAdd" already exists, and only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 defines the mapping from "<Leader>a" if it doesn't. The user then has a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921 chance of putting this in his vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923 map ,c <Plug>TypecorrAdd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1925 Then the mapped key sequence will be ",c" instead of "_a" or "\a".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928 PIECES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 If a script gets longer, you often want to break up the work in pieces. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931 can use functions or mappings for this. But you don't want these functions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 and mappings to interfere with the ones from other scripts. For example, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933 could define a function Add(), but another script could try to define the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 function. To avoid this, we define the function local to the script by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 prepending it with "s:".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 We will define a function that adds a new typing correction: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 31 let to = input("type the correction for " . a:from . ": ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1941 32 exe ":iabbrev " . a:from . " " . to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 Now we can call the function s:Add() from within this script. If another
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946 script also defines s:Add(), it will be local to that script and can only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 be called from the script it was defined in. There can also be a global Add()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948 function (without the "s:"), which is again another function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1950 <SID> can be used with mappings. It generates a script ID, which identifies
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1951 the current script. In our typing correction plugin we use it like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1952
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1953 24 noremap <unique> <script> <Plug>TypecorrAdd <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1954 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1955 28 noremap <SID>Add :call <SID>Add(expand("<cword>"), 1)<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1956
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1957 Thus when a user types "\a", this sequence is invoked: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1958
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959 \a -> <Plug>TypecorrAdd -> <SID>Add -> :call <SID>Add()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1960
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961 If another script would also map <SID>Add, it would get another script ID and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 thus define another mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 Note that instead of s:Add() we use <SID>Add() here. That is because the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965 mapping is typed by the user, thus outside of the script. The <SID> is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966 translated to the script ID, so that Vim knows in which script to look for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967 the Add() function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969 This is a bit complicated, but it's required for the plugin to work together
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 with other plugins. The basic rule is that you use <SID>Add() in mappings and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 s:Add() in other places (the script itself, autocommands, user commands).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 We can also add a menu entry to do the same as the mapping: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975 26 noremenu <script> Plugin.Add\ Correction <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977 The "Plugin" menu is recommended for adding menu items for plugins. In this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1978 case only one item is used. When adding more items, creating a submenu is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 recommended. For example, "Plugin.CVS" could be used for a plugin that offers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1980 CVS operations "Plugin.CVS.checkin", "Plugin.CVS.checkout", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1981
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1982 Note that in line 28 ":noremap" is used to avoid that any other mappings cause
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1983 trouble. Someone may have remapped ":call", for example. In line 24 we also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 use ":noremap", but we do want "<SID>Add" to be remapped. This is why
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985 "<script>" is used here. This only allows mappings which are local to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986 script. |:map-<script>| The same is done in line 26 for ":noremenu".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 |:menu-<script>|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1988
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990 <SID> AND <Plug> *using-<Plug>*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992 Both <SID> and <Plug> are used to avoid that mappings of typed keys interfere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993 with mappings that are only to be used from other mappings. Note the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1994 difference between using <SID> and <Plug>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1995
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 <Plug> is visible outside of the script. It is used for mappings which the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1997 user might want to map a key sequence to. <Plug> is a special code
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1998 that a typed key will never produce.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1999 To make it very unlikely that other plugins use the same sequence of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2000 characters, use this structure: <Plug> scriptname mapname
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001 In our example the scriptname is "Typecorr" and the mapname is "Add".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 This results in "<Plug>TypecorrAdd". Only the first character of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 scriptname and mapname is uppercase, so that we can see where mapname
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004 starts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006 <SID> is the script ID, a unique identifier for a script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007 Internally Vim translates <SID> to "<SNR>123_", where "123" can be any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2008 number. Thus a function "<SID>Add()" will have a name "<SNR>11_Add()"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009 in one script, and "<SNR>22_Add()" in another. You can see this if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 you use the ":function" command to get a list of functions. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2011 translation of <SID> in mappings is exactly the same, that's how you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012 can call a script-local function from a mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2013
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 USER COMMAND
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 Now let's add a user command to add a correction: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019 38 if !exists(":Correct")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2020 39 command -nargs=1 Correct :call s:Add(<q-args>, 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021 40 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023 The user command is defined only if no command with the same name already
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 exists. Otherwise we would get an error here. Overriding the existing user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025 command with ":command!" is not a good idea, this would probably make the user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 wonder why the command he defined himself doesn't work. |:command|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2027
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029 SCRIPT VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031 When a variable starts with "s:" it is a script variable. It can only be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 inside a script. Outside the script it's not visible. This avoids trouble
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 with using the same variable name in different scripts. The variables will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 kept as long as Vim is running. And the same variables are used when sourcing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2035 the same script again. |s:var|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 The fun is that these variables can also be used in functions, autocommands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038 and user commands that are defined in the script. In our example we can add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 a few lines to count the number of corrections: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044 ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 34 let s:count = s:count + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046 35 echo s:count . " corrections now"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049 First s:count is initialized to 4 in the script itself. When later the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 s:Add() function is called, it increments s:count. It doesn't matter from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051 where the function was called, since it has been defined in the script, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052 will use the local variables from this script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055 THE RESULT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 Here is the resulting complete example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059 1 " Vim global plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2060 2 " Last Change: 2000 Oct 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061 3 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 4 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2063 5
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2064 6 if exists("g:loaded_typecorr")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2065 7 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2066 8 endif
2325
f177a6431514 Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2301
diff changeset
2067 9 let g:loaded_typecorr = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2068 10
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2069 11 let s:save_cpo = &cpo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2070 12 set cpo&vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2071 13
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2072 14 iabbrev teh the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2073 15 iabbrev otehr other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2074 16 iabbrev wnat want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 17 iabbrev synchronisation
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076 18 \ synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077 19 let s:count = 4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 20
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 21 if !hasmapto('<Plug>TypecorrAdd')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080 22 map <unique> <Leader>a <Plug>TypecorrAdd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081 23 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082 24 noremap <unique> <script> <Plug>TypecorrAdd <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083 25
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2084 26 noremenu <script> Plugin.Add\ Correction <SID>Add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 27
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086 28 noremap <SID>Add :call <SID>Add(expand("<cword>"), 1)<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 29
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 30 function s:Add(from, correct)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089 31 let to = input("type the correction for " . a:from . ": ")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090 32 exe ":iabbrev " . a:from . " " . to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2091 33 if a:correct | exe "normal viws\<C-R>\" \b\e" | endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092 34 let s:count = s:count + 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 35 echo s:count . " corrections now"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 36 endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095 37
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 38 if !exists(":Correct")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097 39 command -nargs=1 Correct :call s:Add(<q-args>, 0)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098 40 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 41
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100 42 let &cpo = s:save_cpo
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
2101 43 unlet s:save_cpo
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2102
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2103 Line 33 wasn't explained yet. It applies the new correction to the word under
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104 the cursor. The |:normal| command is used to use the new abbreviation. Note
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2105 that mappings and abbreviations are expanded here, even though the function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106 was called from a mapping defined with ":noremap".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108 Using "unix" for the 'fileformat' option is recommended. The Vim scripts will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2109 then work everywhere. Scripts with 'fileformat' set to "dos" do not work on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110 Unix. Also see |:source_crnl|. To be sure it is set right, do this before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2111 writing the file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2112
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113 :set fileformat=unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116 DOCUMENTATION *write-local-help*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 It's a good idea to also write some documentation for your plugin. Especially
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2119 when its behavior can be changed by the user. See |add-local-help| for how
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120 they are installed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 Here is a simple example for a plugin help file, called "typecorr.txt": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124 1 *typecorr.txt* Plugin for correcting typing mistakes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2125 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126 3 If you make typing mistakes, this plugin will have them corrected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2127 4 automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129 6 There are currently only a few corrections. Add your own if you like.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130 7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 8 Mappings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132 9 <Leader>a or <Plug>TypecorrAdd
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 10 Add a correction for the word under the cursor.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2135 12 Commands:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136 13 :Correct {word}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137 14 Add a correction for {word}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138 15
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139 16 *typecorr-settings*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140 17 This plugin doesn't have any settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 The first line is actually the only one for which the format matters. It will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143 be extracted from the help file to be put in the "LOCAL ADDITIONS:" section of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144 help.txt |local-additions|. The first "*" must be in the first column of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145 first line. After adding your help file do ":help" and check that the entries
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146 line up nicely.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 You can add more tags inside ** in your help file. But be careful not to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149 existing help tags. You would probably use the name of your plugin in most of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150 them, like "typecorr-settings" in the example.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152 Using references to other parts of the help in || is recommended. This makes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 it easy for the user to find associated help.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156 FILETYPE DETECTION *plugin-filetype*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2157
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158 If your filetype is not already detected by Vim, you should create a filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 detection snippet in a separate file. It is usually in the form of an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160 autocommand that sets the filetype when the file name matches a pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2163 au BufNewFile,BufRead *.foo set filetype=foofoo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165 Write this single-line file as "ftdetect/foofoo.vim" in the first directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166 that appears in 'runtimepath'. For Unix that would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167 "~/.vim/ftdetect/foofoo.vim". The convention is to use the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2168 filetype for the script name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 You can make more complicated checks if you like, for example to inspect the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171 contents of the file to recognize the language. Also see |new-filetype|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2174 SUMMARY *plugin-special*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2176 Summary of special things to use in a plugin:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178 s:name Variables local to the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2179
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2180 <SID> Script-ID, used for mappings and functions local to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2181 the script.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 hasmapto() Function to test if the user already defined a mapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184 for functionality the script offers.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186 <Leader> Value of "mapleader", which the user defines as the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2187 keys that plugin mappings start with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2188
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2189 :map <unique> Give a warning if a mapping already exists.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2190
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2191 :noremap <script> Use only mappings local to the script, not global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2192 mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2193
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2194 exists(":Cmd") Check if a user command already exists.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2196 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2197 *41.12* Writing a filetype plugin *write-filetype-plugin* *ftplugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2199 A filetype plugin is like a global plugin, except that it sets options and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2200 defines mappings for the current buffer only. See |add-filetype-plugin| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2201 how this type of plugin is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2202
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2203 First read the section on global plugins above |41.11|. All that is said there
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2204 also applies to filetype plugins. There are a few extras, which are explained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2205 here. The essential thing is that a filetype plugin should only have an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206 effect on the current buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 DISABLING
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211 If you are writing a filetype plugin to be used by many people, they need a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 chance to disable loading it. Put this at the top of the plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2214 " Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216 finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2217 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218 let b:did_ftplugin = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 This also needs to be used to avoid that the same plugin is executed twice for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221 the same buffer (happens when using an ":edit" command without arguments).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 Now users can disable loading the default plugin completely by making a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224 filetype plugin with only this line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226 let b:did_ftplugin = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228 This does require that the filetype plugin directory comes before $VIMRUNTIME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229 in 'runtimepath'!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231 If you do want to use the default plugin, but overrule one of the settings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2232 you can write the different setting in a script: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2234 setlocal textwidth=70
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2235
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2236 Now write this in the "after" directory, so that it gets sourced after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237 distributed "vim.vim" ftplugin |after-directory|. For Unix this would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2238 "~/.vim/after/ftplugin/vim.vim". Note that the default plugin will have set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2239 "b:did_ftplugin", but it is ignored here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2240
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2241
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2242 OPTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2243
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2244 To make sure the filetype plugin only affects the current buffer use the >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2246 :setlocal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 command to set options. And only set options which are local to a buffer (see
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249 the help for the option to check that). When using |:setlocal| for global
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250 options or options local to a window, the value will change for many buffers,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 and that is not what a filetype plugin should do.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 When an option has a value that is a list of flags or items, consider using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254 "+=" and "-=" to keep the existing value. Be aware that the user may have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 changed an option value already. First resetting to the default value and
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2662
diff changeset
2256 then changing it is often a good idea. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258 :setlocal formatoptions& formatoptions+=ro
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 MAPPINGS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 To make sure mappings will only work in the current buffer use the >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 :map <buffer>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 command. This needs to be combined with the two-step mapping explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268 An example of how to define functionality in a filetype plugin: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270 if !hasmapto('<Plug>JavaImport')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271 map <buffer> <unique> <LocalLeader>i <Plug>JavaImport
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 noremap <buffer> <unique> <Plug>JavaImport oimport ""<Left><Esc>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 |hasmapto()| is used to check if the user has already defined a map to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276 <Plug>JavaImport. If not, then the filetype plugin defines the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 mapping. This starts with |<LocalLeader>|, which allows the user to select
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278 the key(s) he wants filetype plugin mappings to start with. The default is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2279 backslash.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280 "<unique>" is used to give an error message if the mapping already exists or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 overlaps with an existing mapping.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 |:noremap| is used to avoid that any other mappings that the user has defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283 interferes. You might want to use ":noremap <script>" to allow remapping
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 mappings defined in this script that start with <SID>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 The user must have a chance to disable the mappings in a filetype plugin,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287 without disabling everything. Here is an example of how this is done for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288 plugin for the mail filetype: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 " Add mappings, unless the user didn't want this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291 if !exists("no_plugin_maps") && !exists("no_mail_maps")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292 " Quote text by inserting "> "
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2293 if !hasmapto('<Plug>MailQuote')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294 vmap <buffer> <LocalLeader>q <Plug>MailQuote
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 nmap <buffer> <LocalLeader>q <Plug>MailQuote
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297 vnoremap <buffer> <Plug>MailQuote :s/^/> /<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298 nnoremap <buffer> <Plug>MailQuote :.,$s/^/> /<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2299 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2301 Two global variables are used:
11262
214f228718cf Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11229
diff changeset
2302 |no_plugin_maps| disables mappings for all filetype plugins
214f228718cf Update runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 11229
diff changeset
2303 |no_mail_maps| disables mappings for the "mail" filetype
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2304
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2305
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2306 USER COMMANDS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2308 To add a user command for a specific file type, so that it can only be used in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2309 one buffer, use the "-buffer" argument to |:command|. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2310
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2311 :command -buffer Make make %:r.s
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2312
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 VARIABLES
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316 A filetype plugin will be sourced for each buffer of the type it's for. Local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317 script variables |s:var| will be shared between all invocations. Use local
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318 buffer variables |b:var| if you want a variable specifically for one buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2319
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 FUNCTIONS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2322
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323 When defining a function, this only needs to be done once. But the filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 plugin will be sourced every time a file with this filetype will be opened.
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
2325 This construct makes sure the function is only defined once: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327 :if !exists("*s:Func")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 : function s:Func(arg)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329 : ...
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330 : endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333
8061
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2334 UNDO *undo_indent* *undo_ftplugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 When the user does ":setfiletype xyz" the effect of the previous filetype
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2337 should be undone. Set the b:undo_ftplugin variable to the commands that will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338 undo the settings in your filetype plugin. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal fo< com< tw< commentstring<"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341 \ . "| unlet b:match_ignorecase b:match_words b:match_skip"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 Using ":setlocal" with "<" after the option name resets the option to its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344 global value. That is mostly the best way to reset the option value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346 This does require removing the "C" flag from 'cpoptions' to allow line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347 continuation, as mentioned above |use-cpo-save|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2348
8061
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2349 For undoing the effect of an indent script, the b:undo_indent variable should
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2350 be set accordingly.
abd64cf67bcf commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents: 7924
diff changeset
2351
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353 FILE NAME
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 The filetype must be included in the file name |ftplugin-name|. Use one of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 these three forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358 .../ftplugin/stuff.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2359 .../ftplugin/stuff_foo.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360 .../ftplugin/stuff/bar.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 "stuff" is the filetype, "foo" and "bar" are arbitrary names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2365 SUMMARY *ftplugin-special*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2366
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 Summary of special things to use in a filetype plugin:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369 <LocalLeader> Value of "maplocalleader", which the user defines as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 the keys that filetype plugin mappings start with.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372 :map <buffer> Define a mapping local to the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374 :noremap <script> Only remap mappings defined in this script that start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375 with <SID>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2377 :setlocal Set an option for the current buffer only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379 :command -buffer Define a user command local to the buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381 exists("*s:Func") Check if a function was already defined.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2382
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2383 Also see |plugin-special|, the special things used for all plugins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 ==============================================================================
161
6df0106fc595 updated for version 7.0049
vimboss
parents: 158
diff changeset
2386 *41.13* Writing a compiler plugin *write-compiler-plugin*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 A compiler plugin sets options for use with a specific compiler. The user can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 load it with the |:compiler| command. The main use is to set the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390 'errorformat' and 'makeprg' options.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 Easiest is to have a look at examples. This command will edit all the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 compiler plugins: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 :next $VIMRUNTIME/compiler/*.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 Use |:next| to go to the next plugin file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399 There are two special items about these files. First is a mechanism to allow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 a user to overrule or add to the default file. The default files start with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402 :if exists("current_compiler")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2403 : finish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2404 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405 :let current_compiler = "mine"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407 When you write a compiler file and put it in your personal runtime directory
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 (e.g., ~/.vim/compiler for Unix), you set the "current_compiler" variable to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 make the default file skip the settings.
570
27d1ec742f17 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 434
diff changeset
2410 *:CompilerSet*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 The second mechanism is to use ":set" for ":compiler!" and ":setlocal" for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412 ":compiler". Vim defines the ":CompilerSet" user command for this. However,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413 older Vim versions don't, thus your plugin should define it then. This is an
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416 if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419 CompilerSet errorformat& " use the default 'errorformat'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 CompilerSet makeprg=nmake
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 When you write a compiler plugin for the Vim distribution or for a system-wide
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423 runtime directory, use the mechanism mentioned above. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 "current_compiler" was already set by a user plugin nothing will be done.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426 When you write a compiler plugin to overrule settings from a default plugin,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427 don't check "current_compiler". This plugin is supposed to be loaded
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428 last, thus it should be in a directory at the end of 'runtimepath'. For Unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2429 that could be ~/.vim/after/compiler.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2431 ==============================================================================
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2432 *41.14* Writing a plugin that loads quickly *write-plugin-quickload*
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2433
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2434 A plugin may grow and become quite long. The startup delay may become
1620
73fe8baea242 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1326
diff changeset
2435 noticeable, while you hardly ever use the plugin. Then it's time for a
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2436 quickload plugin.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2437
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2438 The basic idea is that the plugin is loaded twice. The first time user
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2439 commands and mappings are defined that offer the functionality. The second
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2440 time the functions that implement the functionality are defined.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2441
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2442 It may sound surprising that quickload means loading a script twice. What we
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2443 mean is that it loads quickly the first time, postponing the bulk of the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2444 script to the second time, which only happens when you actually use it. When
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2445 you always use the functionality it actually gets slower!
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2446
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2447 Note that since Vim 7 there is an alternative: use the |autoload|
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2448 functionality |41.15|.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2449
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2450 The following example shows how it's done: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2451
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2452 " Vim global plugin for demonstrating quick loading
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2453 " Last Change: 2005 Feb 25
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2454 " Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2455 " License: This file is placed in the public domain.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2456
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2457 if !exists("s:did_load")
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2458 command -nargs=* BNRead call BufNetRead(<f-args>)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2459 map <F19> :call BufNetWrite('something')<CR>
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2460
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2461 let s:did_load = 1
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2462 exe 'au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ' . expand('<sfile>')
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2463 finish
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2464 endif
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2465
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2466 function BufNetRead(...)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2467 echo 'BufNetRead(' . string(a:000) . ')'
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2468 " read functionality here
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2469 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2470
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2471 function BufNetWrite(...)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2472 echo 'BufNetWrite(' . string(a:000) . ')'
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2473 " write functionality here
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2474 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2475
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2476 When the script is first loaded "s:did_load" is not set. The commands between
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2477 the "if" and "endif" will be executed. This ends in a |:finish| command, thus
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2478 the rest of the script is not executed.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2479
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2480 The second time the script is loaded "s:did_load" exists and the commands
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2481 after the "endif" are executed. This defines the (possible long)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2482 BufNetRead() and BufNetWrite() functions.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2483
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2484 If you drop this script in your plugin directory Vim will execute it on
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2485 startup. This is the sequence of events that happens:
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2486
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2487 1. The "BNRead" command is defined and the <F19> key is mapped when the script
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2488 is sourced at startup. A |FuncUndefined| autocommand is defined. The
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2489 ":finish" command causes the script to terminate early.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2490
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2491 2. The user types the BNRead command or presses the <F19> key. The
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2492 BufNetRead() or BufNetWrite() function will be called.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
2493
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2494 3. Vim can't find the function and triggers the |FuncUndefined| autocommand
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2495 event. Since the pattern "BufNet*" matches the invoked function, the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2496 command "source fname" will be executed. "fname" will be equal to the name
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2497 of the script, no matter where it is located, because it comes from
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2498 expanding "<sfile>" (see |expand()|).
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2499
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2500 4. The script is sourced again, the "s:did_load" variable exists and the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2501 functions are defined.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2502
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2503 Notice that the functions that are loaded afterwards match the pattern in the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2504 |FuncUndefined| autocommand. You must make sure that no other plugin defines
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2505 functions that match this pattern.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2506
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2507 ==============================================================================
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2508 *41.15* Writing library scripts *write-library-script*
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2509
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2510 Some functionality will be required in several places. When this becomes more
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2511 than a few lines you will want to put it in one script and use it from many
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2512 scripts. We will call that one script a library script.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2513
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2514 Manually loading a library script is possible, so long as you avoid loading it
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2515 when it's already done. You can do this with the |exists()| function.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2516 Example: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2517
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2518 if !exists('*MyLibFunction')
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2519 runtime library/mylibscript.vim
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2520 endif
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2521 call MyLibFunction(arg)
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2522
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2523 Here you need to know that MyLibFunction() is defined in a script
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2524 "library/mylibscript.vim" in one of the directories in 'runtimepath'.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2525
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2526 To make this a bit simpler Vim offers the autoload mechanism. Then the
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2527 example looks like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2528
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2529 call mylib#myfunction(arg)
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2530
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2531 That's a lot simpler, isn't it? Vim will recognize the function name and when
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2532 it's not defined search for the script "autoload/mylib.vim" in 'runtimepath'.
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2533 That script must define the "mylib#myfunction()" function.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2534
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2535 You can put many other functions in the mylib.vim script, you are free to
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2536 organize your functions in library scripts. But you must use function names
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2537 where the part before the '#' matches the script name. Otherwise Vim would
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2538 not know what script to load.
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2539
681
9364d114ed8d updated for version 7.0204
vimboss
parents: 667
diff changeset
2540 If you get really enthusiastic and write lots of library scripts, you may
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2541 want to use subdirectories. Example: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2542
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2543 call netlib#ftp#read('somefile')
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2544
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2545 For Unix the library script used for this could be:
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2546
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2547 ~/.vim/autoload/netlib/ftp.vim
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2548
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2549 Where the function is defined like this: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2550
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2551 function netlib#ftp#read(fname)
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2552 " Read the file fname through ftp
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2553 endfunction
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2554
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2555 Notice that the name the function is defined with is exactly the same as the
323
03b3684919e3 updated for version 7.0084
vimboss
parents: 270
diff changeset
2556 name used for calling the function. And the part before the last '#'
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2557 exactly matches the subdirectory and script name.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2558
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2559 You can use the same mechanism for variables: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2560
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2561 let weekdays = dutch#weekdays
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2562
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2563 This will load the script "autoload/dutch.vim", which should contain something
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2564 like: >
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2565
270
a20218704019 updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 230
diff changeset
2566 let dutch#weekdays = ['zondag', 'maandag', 'dinsdag', 'woensdag',
170
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2567 \ 'donderdag', 'vrijdag', 'zaterdag']
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2568
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2569 Further reading: |autoload|.
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2570
8c60f65311fa updated for version 7.0052
vimboss
parents: 164
diff changeset
2571 ==============================================================================
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2572 *41.16* Distributing Vim scripts *distribute-script*
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2573
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2574 Vim users will look for scripts on the Vim website: http://www.vim.org.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2575 If you made something that is useful for others, share it!
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2576
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2577 Vim scripts can be used on any system. There might not be a tar or gzip
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2578 command. If you want to pack files together and/or compress them the "zip"
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2579 utility is recommended.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2580
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2581 For utmost portability use Vim itself to pack scripts together. This can be
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2582 done with the Vimball utility. See |vimball|.
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2583
799
6beb2c667935 updated for version 7.0b
vimboss
parents: 793
diff changeset
2584 It's good if you add a line to allow automatic updating. See |glvs-plugins|.
6beb2c667935 updated for version 7.0b
vimboss
parents: 793
diff changeset
2585
793
8c0b00d50acf updated for version 7.0231
vimboss
parents: 681
diff changeset
2586 ==============================================================================
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2587
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2588 Next chapter: |usr_42.txt| Add new menus
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2589
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2590 Copyright: see |manual-copyright| vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: